xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 5f60d5f6)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2024 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218  *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220  *	was changed.
221  */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
224 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
225 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
226 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
227 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
228 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
229 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234  * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235  * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236  *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237  */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242 
243 /**
244  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245  *
246  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248  *
249  * @def: the channel definition
250  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251  * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252  *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253  * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262  */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267 
268 	int radio_idx;
269 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270 
271 	bool radar_enabled;
272 
273 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275 
276 /**
277  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
281  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288  *      for changes/removal.)
289  */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294 
295 /**
296  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297  *
298  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
300  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301  * done.
302  *
303  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307  */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314 
315 /**
316  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317  *
318  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320  *
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322  *	also implies a change in the AID.
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
333  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346  *	changed
347  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351  *	context had been assigned.
352  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355  *	keep alive) changed.
356  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364  *	status changed.
365  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367  * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368  */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
381 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
382 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
383 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
384 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
385 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
386 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
387 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
388 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
389 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
390 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
391 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
392 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
393 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
394 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
395 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
396 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
397 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
398 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
399 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
400 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
401 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
403 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
404 	BSS_CHANGED_TPE			= BIT_ULL(35),
405 
406 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408 
409 /*
410  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412  * filtering will be disabled.
413  */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415 
416 /**
417  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
424  */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 	RSSI_EVENT,
427 	MLME_EVENT,
428 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431 
432 /**
433  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436  */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445  */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456  */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 	AUTH_EVENT,
459 	ASSOC_EVENT,
460 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463 
464 /**
465  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469  */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 	MLME_SUCCESS,
472 	MLME_DENIED,
473 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475 
476 /**
477  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 	u16 reason;
486 };
487 
488 /**
489  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491  * @tid: the tid
492  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493  */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 	u16 tid;
497 	u16 ssn;
498 };
499 
500 /**
501  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506  * @u:union holding the fields above
507  */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 	union {
511 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 	} u;
515 };
516 
517 /**
518  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519  *
520  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521  *
522  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524  */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529 
530 /**
531  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532  *
533  * @lci: LCI subelement content
534  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535  * @lci_len: LCI data length
536  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537  */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 	const u8 *lci;
540 	const u8 *civicloc;
541 	size_t lci_len;
542 	size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544 
545 /**
546  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548  *
549  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551  */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 	u32 min_interval;
554 	u32 max_interval;
555 };
556 
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ	5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 	bool valid;
560 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 	u8 count;
562 };
563 
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ	16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 	bool valid;
567 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 	u8 count, n;
569 };
570 
571 /**
572  * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573  * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574  *	(indexed by TX power category)
575  * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576  *	160, 320 MHz each
577  *	(indexed by TX power category)
578  * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579  *	subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580  *	(indexed by TX power category)
581  * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582  *	each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583  *	(indexed by TX power category)
584  */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589 
590 /**
591  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592  *
593  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595  *
596  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597  * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598  *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599  *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600  *	responses.
601  * @addr: (link) address used locally
602  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640  *	the current band.
641  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645  * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
656  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
664  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680  *	station.
681  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682  *	responder functionality.
683  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
686  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
687  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
688  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
689  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
690  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
691  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
692  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
693  *	connected to (STA)
694  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
695  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
696  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
697  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
698  *	interval.
699  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
700  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
701  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
702  * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
703  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
704  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
705  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
706  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
707  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
708  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
709  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
710  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
711  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
712  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
713  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
714  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
715  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
716  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
717  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
718  *	beamformer
719  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
720  *	beamformee
721  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
722  *	beamformer
723  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
724  *	beamformee
725  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
726  *	beamformer
727  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
728  *	beamformee
729  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
730  *	beamformer
731  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
732  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
733  *	bandwidth
734  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
735  *	beamformer
736  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
737  *	beamformee
738  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
739  *	beamformer
740  * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
741  *	reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
742  *	bandwidth
743  */
744 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
745 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
746 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
747 
748 	const u8 *bssid;
749 	unsigned int link_id;
750 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
751 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
752 	bool uora_exists;
753 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
754 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
755 	bool he_support;
756 	bool twt_requester;
757 	bool twt_responder;
758 	bool twt_protected;
759 	bool twt_broadcast;
760 	/* erp related data */
761 	bool use_cts_prot;
762 	bool use_short_preamble;
763 	bool use_short_slot;
764 	bool enable_beacon;
765 	u8 dtim_period;
766 	u16 beacon_int;
767 	u16 assoc_capability;
768 	u64 sync_tsf;
769 	u32 sync_device_ts;
770 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
771 	u32 basic_rates;
772 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
773 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
774 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
775 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
776 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
777 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
778 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
779 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
780 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
781 	bool qos;
782 	bool hidden_ssid;
783 	int txpower;
784 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
785 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
786 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
787 	u16 max_idle_period;
788 	bool protected_keep_alive;
789 	bool ftm_responder;
790 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
791 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
792 	bool nontransmitted;
793 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
794 	u8 bssid_index;
795 	u8 bssid_indicator;
796 	bool ema_ap;
797 	u8 profile_periodicity;
798 	struct {
799 		u32 params;
800 		u16 nss_set;
801 	} he_oper;
802 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
803 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
804 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
805 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
806 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
807 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
808 
809 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
810 
811 	u8 pwr_reduction;
812 	bool eht_support;
813 
814 	bool csa_active;
815 
816 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
817 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
818 
819 	bool color_change_active;
820 	u8 color_change_color;
821 
822 	bool ht_ldpc;
823 	bool vht_ldpc;
824 	bool he_ldpc;
825 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
826 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
827 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
828 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
829 	bool he_su_beamformer;
830 	bool he_su_beamformee;
831 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
832 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
833 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
834 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
835 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
836 	bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
837 };
838 
839 /**
840  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
841  *
842  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
843  *
844  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
845  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
846  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
847  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
848  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
849  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
850  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
851  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
852  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
853  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
854  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
855  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
856  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
857  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
858  *	station
859  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
860  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
861  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
862  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
863  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
864  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
865  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
866  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
867  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
868  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
869  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
870  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
871  *	hardware queue.
872  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
873  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
874  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
875  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
876  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
877  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
878  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
879  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
880  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
881  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
882  *	off-channel operation.
883  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
884  *	(header conversion)
885  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
886  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
887  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
888  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
889  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
890  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
891  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
892  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
893  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
894  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
895  *	queue gets full.
896  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
897  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
898  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
899  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
900  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
901  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
902  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
903  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
904  *	status to user space)
905  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
906  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
907  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
908  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
909  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
910  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
911  *	handled properly by the device.
912  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
913  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
914  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
915  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
916  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
917  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
918  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
919  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
920  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
921  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
922  *	PS-Poll responses.
923  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
924  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
925  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
927  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
928  *	monitor injection).
929  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
930  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
931  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
932  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
933  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
934  *
935  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
936  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
937  */
938 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
939 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
940 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
941 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
942 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
943 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
944 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
945 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
946 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
947 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
948 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
949 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
950 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
951 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
952 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
953 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
954 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
955 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
956 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
957 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
958 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
959 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
960 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
961 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
962 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
963 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
964 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
965 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
966 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
967 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
968 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
969 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
970 };
971 
972 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
973 
974 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
975 
976 /**
977  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
978  *
979  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
980  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
981  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
982  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
983  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
984  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
985  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
986  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
987  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
988  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
989  *	it can be sent out.
990  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
991  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
992  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
993  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
994  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
995  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
996  *	for sequence number assignment
997  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
998  *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
999  *	operation on the interface.
1000  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1001  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1002  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1003  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1004  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1005  *	it's intended for an MLD.
1006  *
1007  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1008  */
1009 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1010 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
1011 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
1012 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
1013 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
1014 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
1015 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
1016 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
1017 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
1018 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
1019 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
1020 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
1021 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
1022 };
1023 
1024 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
1025 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
1026 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1027 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1028 
1029 /**
1030  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1031  *
1032  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1033  *
1034  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1035  */
1036 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1037 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1038 };
1039 
1040 /*
1041  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1042  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1043  */
1044 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1045 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1046 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1047 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1048 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1049 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1050 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1051 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1052 
1053 /**
1054  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1055  *	Rate Control algorithm.
1056  *
1057  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1058  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1059  *
1060  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1061  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1062  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1063  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1064  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1065  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1066  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1067  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1068  *	Greenfield mode.
1069  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1070  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1071  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1072  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1073  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1074  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1075  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1076  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1077  */
1078 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1079 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1080 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1081 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1082 
1083 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1084 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1085 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1086 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1087 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1088 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1089 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1090 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1091 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1092 };
1093 
1094 
1095 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1096 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1097 
1098 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1099 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1100 
1101 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1102 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1103 
1104 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1105 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1106 
1107 /**
1108  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1109  *
1110  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1111  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1112  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1113  *
1114  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1115  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1116  *
1117  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1118  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1119  *
1120  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1121  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1122  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1123  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1124  * information::
1125  *
1126  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1127  *
1128  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1129  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1130  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1131  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1132  * information should then contain::
1133  *
1134  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1135  *
1136  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1137  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1138  */
1139 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1140 	s8 idx;
1141 	u16 count:5,
1142 	    flags:11;
1143 } __packed;
1144 
1145 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1146 
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1147 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1148 {
1149 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1150 }
1151 
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1152 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1153 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1154 {
1155 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1156 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1157 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1158 }
1159 
1160 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1161 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1162 {
1163 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1164 }
1165 
1166 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1167 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1168 {
1169 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1170 }
1171 
1172 /**
1173  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1174  *
1175  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1176  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1177  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1178  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1179  *
1180  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1181  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1182  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1183  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1184  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1185  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1186  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1187  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1188  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1189  * @control: union part for control data
1190  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1191  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1192  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1193  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1194  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1195  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1196  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1197  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1198  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1199  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1200  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1201  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1202  * @pad: padding
1203  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1204  * @status: union part for status data
1205  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1206  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1207  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1208  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1209  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1210  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1211  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1212  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1213  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1214  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1215  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1216  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1217  */
1218 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1219 	/* common information */
1220 	u32 flags;
1221 	u32 band:3,
1222 	    status_data_idr:1,
1223 	    status_data:13,
1224 	    hw_queue:4,
1225 	    tx_time_est:10;
1226 	/* 1 free bit */
1227 
1228 	union {
1229 		struct {
1230 			union {
1231 				/* rate control */
1232 				struct {
1233 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1234 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1235 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1236 					u8 use_rts:1;
1237 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1238 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1239 					u8 skip_table:1;
1240 
1241 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1242 					u8 antennas:2;
1243 
1244 					/* 14 bits free */
1245 				};
1246 				/* only needed before rate control */
1247 				unsigned long jiffies;
1248 			};
1249 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1250 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1251 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1252 			u32 flags;
1253 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1254 		} control;
1255 		struct {
1256 			u64 cookie;
1257 		} ack;
1258 		struct {
1259 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1260 			s32 ack_signal;
1261 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1262 			u8 ampdu_len;
1263 			u8 antenna;
1264 			u8 pad;
1265 			u16 tx_time;
1266 			u8 flags;
1267 			u8 pad2;
1268 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1269 		} status;
1270 		struct {
1271 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1272 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1273 			u8 pad[4];
1274 
1275 			void *rate_driver_data[
1276 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1277 		};
1278 		void *driver_data[
1279 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1280 	};
1281 };
1282 
1283 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1284 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1285 {
1286 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1287 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1288 	 */
1289 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1290 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1291 }
1292 
1293 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1294 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1295 {
1296 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1297 }
1298 
1299 /***
1300  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1301  *
1302  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1303  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1304  *
1305  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1306  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1307  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1308  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1309  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1310  */
1311 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1312 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1313 	u8 try_count;
1314 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1315 };
1316 
1317 /**
1318  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1319  *
1320  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1321  * @info: Basic tx status information
1322  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1323  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1324  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1325  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1326  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1327  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1328  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1329  */
1330 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1331 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1332 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1333 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1334 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1335 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1336 	u8 n_rates;
1337 
1338 	struct list_head *free_list;
1339 };
1340 
1341 /**
1342  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1343  *
1344  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1345  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1346  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1347  *
1348  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1349  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1350  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1351  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1352  */
1353 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1354 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1355 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1356 	const u8 *common_ies;
1357 	size_t common_ie_len;
1358 };
1359 
1360 
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1361 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1362 {
1363 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1364 }
1365 
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1366 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1367 {
1368 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1369 }
1370 
1371 /**
1372  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1373  *
1374  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1375  *
1376  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1377  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1378  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1379  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1380  *
1381  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1382  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1383  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1384  */
1385 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1386 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1387 {
1388 	int i;
1389 
1390 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1391 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1392 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1393 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1394 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1395 	/* clear the rate counts */
1396 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1397 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1398 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1399 }
1400 
1401 
1402 /**
1403  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1404  *
1405  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1406  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1407  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1408  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1409  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1410  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1411  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1412  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1413  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1414  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1415  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1416  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1417  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1418  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1419  *	de-duplication by itself.
1420  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1421  *	the frame.
1422  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1423  *	the frame.
1424  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1425  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1426  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1427  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1428  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1429  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1430  *	merging.
1431  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1432  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1433  *	(including FCS) was received.
1434  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1435  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1436  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1437  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1438  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1439  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1440  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1441  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1442  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1443  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1444  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1445  *	each A-MPDU
1446  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1447  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1448  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1449  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1450  *	on this subframe
1451  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1452  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1453  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1454  *	done by the hardware
1455  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1456  *	processing it in any regular way.
1457  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1458  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1459  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1460  *	monitor interfaces.
1461  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1462  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1463  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1464  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1465  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1466  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1467  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1468  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1469  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1470  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1471  *	interleaved with other frames.
1472  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1473  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1474  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1475  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1476  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1477  *	in the skb.
1478  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1479  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1480  *	the first subframe.
1481  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1482  *	be done in the hardware.
1483  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1484  *	frame
1485  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1486  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1487  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1488  *
1489  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1490  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1491  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1492  *	 - DATA5_GI
1493  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1494  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1495  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1496  *
1497  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1498  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1499  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1500  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1501  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1502  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1503  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1504  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1505  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1506  *	hardware or driver)
1507  */
1508 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1509 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1510 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1511 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1512 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1513 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1514 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1515 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1516 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1517 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1518 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1519 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1520 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1521 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1522 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1523 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1524 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1525 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1526 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1527 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1528 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1529 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1530 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1531 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1532 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1533 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1534 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1535 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1536 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1537 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1538 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1539 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1540 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1541 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1542 };
1543 
1544 /**
1545  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1546  *
1547  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1548  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1549  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1550  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1551  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1552  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1553  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1554  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1555  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1556  */
1557 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1558 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1559 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1560 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1561 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1562 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1563 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1564 };
1565 
1566 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1567 
1568 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1569 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1570 	RX_ENC_HT,
1571 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1572 	RX_ENC_HE,
1573 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1574 };
1575 
1576 /**
1577  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1578  *
1579  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1580  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1581  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1582  *
1583  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1584  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1585  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1586  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1587  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1588  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1589  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1590  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1591  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1592  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1593  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1594  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1595  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1596  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1597  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1598  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1599  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1600  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1601  *	values were filled.
1602  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1603  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1604  * @antenna: antenna used
1605  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1606  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1607  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1608  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1609  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1610  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1611  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1612  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1613  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1614  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1615  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1616  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1617  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1618  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1619  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1620  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1621  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1622  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1623  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1624  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1625  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1626  *	@link_valid.
1627  */
1628 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1629 	u64 mactime;
1630 	union {
1631 		u64 boottime_ns;
1632 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1633 	};
1634 	u32 device_timestamp;
1635 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1636 	u32 flag;
1637 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1638 	u8 enc_flags;
1639 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1640 	union {
1641 		struct {
1642 			u8 he_ru:3;
1643 			u8 he_gi:2;
1644 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1645 		};
1646 		struct {
1647 			u8 ru:4;
1648 			u8 gi:2;
1649 		} eht;
1650 	};
1651 	u8 rate_idx;
1652 	u8 nss;
1653 	u8 rx_flags;
1654 	u8 band;
1655 	u8 antenna;
1656 	s8 signal;
1657 	u8 chains;
1658 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1659 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1660 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1661 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1662 };
1663 
1664 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1665 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1666 {
1667 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1668 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1669 }
1670 
1671 /**
1672  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1673  *
1674  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1675  *
1676  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1677  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1678  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1679  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1680  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1681  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1682  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1683  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1684  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1685  *	for more.
1686  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1687  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1688  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1689  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1690  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1691  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1692  *	operating channel.
1693  */
1694 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1695 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1696 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1697 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1698 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1699 };
1700 
1701 
1702 /**
1703  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1704  *
1705  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1706  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1707  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1708  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1709  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1710  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1711  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1712  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1713  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1714  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1715  */
1716 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1717 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1718 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1719 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1720 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1721 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1722 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1723 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1724 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1725 };
1726 
1727 /**
1728  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1729  *
1730  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1731  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1732  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1733  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1734  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1735  */
1736 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1737 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1738 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1739 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1740 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1741 
1742 	/* keep last */
1743 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1744 };
1745 
1746 /**
1747  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1748  *
1749  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1750  *
1751  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1752  *
1753  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1754  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1755  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1756  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1757  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1758  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1759  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1760  *
1761  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1762  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1763  *
1764  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1765  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1766  *
1767  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1768  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1769  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1770  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1771  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1772  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1773  *
1774  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1775  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1776  *	configured for an HT channel.
1777  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1778  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1779  */
1780 struct ieee80211_conf {
1781 	u32 flags;
1782 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1783 
1784 	u16 listen_interval;
1785 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1786 
1787 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1788 
1789 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1790 	bool radar_enabled;
1791 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1792 };
1793 
1794 /**
1795  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1796  *
1797  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1798  * operation.
1799  *
1800  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1801  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1802  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1803  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1804  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1805  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1806  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1807  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1808  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1809  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1810  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1811  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1812  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1813  * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1814  */
1815 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1816 	u64 timestamp;
1817 	u32 device_timestamp;
1818 	bool block_tx;
1819 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1820 	u8 count;
1821 	u8 link_id;
1822 	u32 delay;
1823 };
1824 
1825 /**
1826  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1827  *
1828  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1829  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1830  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1831  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1832  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1833  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1834  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1835  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1836  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1837  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1838  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1839  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1840  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1841  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1842  *      enabled for the interface.
1843  * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1844  *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1845  *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1846  *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1847  */
1848 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1849 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1850 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1851 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1852 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1853 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1854 	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1855 };
1856 
1857 
1858 /**
1859  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1860  *
1861  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1862  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1863  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1864  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1865  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1866  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1867  *	mac80211.
1868  */
1869 
1870 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1871 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1872 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1873 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1874 };
1875 
1876 /**
1877  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1878  * @assoc: association status
1879  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1880  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1881  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1882  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1883  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1884  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1885  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1886  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1887  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1888  *	Figure 9-1001k
1889  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1890  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1891  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1892  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1893  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1894  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1895  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1896  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1897  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1898  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1899  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1900  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1901  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1902  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1903  *	(station mode only)
1904  */
1905 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1906 	/* association related data */
1907 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1908 	bool ibss_creator;
1909 	bool ps;
1910 	u16 aid;
1911 	u16 eml_cap;
1912 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1913 	u16 mld_capa_op;
1914 
1915 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1916 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1917 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1918 	size_t ssid_len;
1919 	bool s1g;
1920 	bool idle;
1921 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1922 };
1923 
1924 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1925 
1926 /**
1927  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1928  *
1929  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1930  *	this TID is not included.
1931  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1932  *	TID is not included.
1933  * @valid: info is valid or not.
1934  */
1935 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1936 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1937 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1938 	bool valid;
1939 };
1940 
1941 /**
1942  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1943  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1944  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1945  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1946  */
1947 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1948 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1949 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1950 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1951 };
1952 
1953 /**
1954  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1955  *
1956  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1957  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1958  *
1959  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1960  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1961  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1962  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1963  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1964  *	indexed by link ID
1965  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1966  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1967  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1968  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1969  * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1970  *	due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1971  *	0 for non-MLO.
1972  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1973  *	suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1974  *	future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1975  *	0 for non-MLO.
1976  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1977  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1978  * @addr: address of this interface
1979  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1980  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1981  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1982  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1983  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1984  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1985  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1986  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1987  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1988  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1989  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1990  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1991  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1992  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1993  *	restrictions.
1994  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1995  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1996  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1997  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1998  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1999  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2000  *	interface.
2001  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2002  *	for this interface.
2003  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2004  *	sizeof(void \*).
2005  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2006  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2007  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2008  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2009  */
2010 struct ieee80211_vif {
2011 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
2012 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2013 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2014 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2015 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2016 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2017 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2018 	bool p2p;
2019 
2020 	u8 cab_queue;
2021 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2022 
2023 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2024 
2025 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2026 	u32 driver_flags;
2027 	u32 offload_flags;
2028 
2029 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2030 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2031 #endif
2032 
2033 	bool probe_req_reg;
2034 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2035 
2036 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2037 
2038 	/* must be last */
2039 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2040 };
2041 
2042 /**
2043  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2044  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2045  * Return: the usable link bitmap
2046  */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2047 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2048 {
2049 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2050 }
2051 
2052 /**
2053  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2054  * @vif: the vif
2055  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2056  */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2057 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2058 {
2059 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2060 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2061 }
2062 
2063 /**
2064  * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2065  * @vif: the vif
2066  * @link_id: the link ID to check
2067  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2068  *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2069  */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2070 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2071 					     unsigned int link_id)
2072 {
2073 	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2074 		return link_id == 0;
2075 	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2076 }
2077 
2078 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2079 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2080 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2081 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2082 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2083 
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2084 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2085 {
2086 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2087 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2088 #endif
2089 	return false;
2090 }
2091 
2092 /**
2093  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2094  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2095  *
2096  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2097  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2098  *
2099  * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2100  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2101  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2102  */
2103 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2104 
2105 /**
2106  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2107  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2108  *
2109  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2110  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2111  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2112  *
2113  * Return: pointer to the wdev
2114  */
2115 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2116 
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2117 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2118 {
2119 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2120 }
2121 
2122 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2123 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2124 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2125 
2126 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2127 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2128 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2129 
2130 /**
2131  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2132  *
2133  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2134  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2135  *
2136  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2137  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2138  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2139  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2140  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2141  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2142  *	generation in software.
2143  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2144  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2145  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2146  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2147  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2148  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2149  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2150  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2151  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2152  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2153  *	MIC.
2154  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2155  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2156  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2157  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2158  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2159  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2160  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2161  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2162  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2163  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2164  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2165  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2166  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2167  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2168  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2169  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2170  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2171  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2172  *	for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2173  *	number generation only
2174  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2175  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2176  */
2177 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2178 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2179 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2180 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2181 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2182 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2183 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2184 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2185 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2186 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2187 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2188 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2189 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2190 };
2191 
2192 /**
2193  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2194  *
2195  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2196  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2197  *
2198  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2199  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2200  *	encrypted in hardware.
2201  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2202  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2203  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2204  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2205  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2206  * @keylen: key material length
2207  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2208  * 	data block:
2209  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2210  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2211  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2212  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2213  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2214  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2215  */
2216 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2217 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2218 	u32 cipher;
2219 	u8 icv_len;
2220 	u8 iv_len;
2221 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2222 	s8 keyidx;
2223 	u16 flags;
2224 	s8 link_id;
2225 	u8 keylen;
2226 	u8 key[];
2227 };
2228 
2229 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2230 
2231 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2232 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2233 
2234 /**
2235  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2236  *
2237  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2238  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2239  *	reverse order than in packet)
2240  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2241  *	reverse order than in packet)
2242  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2243  *	reverse order than in packet)
2244  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2245  *	reverse order than in packet)
2246  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2247  */
2248 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2249 	union {
2250 		struct {
2251 			u32 iv32;
2252 			u16 iv16;
2253 		} tkip;
2254 		struct {
2255 			u8 pn[6];
2256 		} ccmp;
2257 		struct {
2258 			u8 pn[6];
2259 		} aes_cmac;
2260 		struct {
2261 			u8 pn[6];
2262 		} aes_gmac;
2263 		struct {
2264 			u8 pn[6];
2265 		} gcmp;
2266 		struct {
2267 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2268 			u8 seq_len;
2269 		} hw;
2270 	};
2271 };
2272 
2273 /**
2274  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2275  *
2276  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2277  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2278  *
2279  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2280  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2281  */
2282 enum set_key_cmd {
2283 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2284 };
2285 
2286 /**
2287  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2288  *
2289  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2290  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2291  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2292  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2293  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2294  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2295  */
2296 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2297 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2298 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2299 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2300 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2301 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2302 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2303 };
2304 
2305 /**
2306  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2307  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2308  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2309  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2310  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2311  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2312  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2313  *
2314  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2315  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2316  */
2317 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2318 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2319 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2320 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2321 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2322 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2323 };
2324 
2325 /**
2326  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2327  *
2328  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2329  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2330  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2331  */
2332 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2333 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2334 	struct {
2335 		s8 idx;
2336 		u8 count;
2337 		u8 count_cts;
2338 		u8 count_rts;
2339 		u16 flags;
2340 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2341 };
2342 
2343 /**
2344  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2345  *
2346  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2347  *
2348  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2349  *	to the STA.
2350  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2351  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2352  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2353  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2354  *	per peer TPC.
2355  */
2356 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2357 	s16 power;
2358 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2359 };
2360 
2361 /**
2362  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2363  *
2364  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2365  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2366  *
2367  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2368  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2369  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2370  *
2371  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2372  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2373  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2374  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2375  *
2376  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2377  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2378  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2379  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2380  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2381  */
2382 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2383 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2384 
2385 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2386 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2387 };
2388 
2389 /**
2390  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2391  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2392  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2393  *
2394  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2395  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2396  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2397  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2398  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2399  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2400  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2401  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2402  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2403  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2404  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2405  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2406  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2407  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2408  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2409  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2410  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2411  *	the station moves to associated state.
2412  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2413  *
2414  */
2415 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2416 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2417 
2418 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2419 	u8 link_id;
2420 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2421 
2422 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2423 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2424 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2425 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2426 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2427 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2428 
2429 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2430 
2431 	u8 rx_nss;
2432 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2433 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2434 };
2435 
2436 /**
2437  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2438  *
2439  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2440  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2441  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2442  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2443  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2444  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2445  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2446  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2447  *
2448  * @addr: MAC address
2449  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2450  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2451  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2452  *	Can be modified by driver.
2453  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2454  *	otherwise always false)
2455  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2456  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2457  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2458  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2459  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2460  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2461  * @rates: rate control selection table
2462  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2463  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2464  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2465  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2466  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2467  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2468  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2469  *	unlimited.
2470  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2471  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2472  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2473  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2474  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2475  *	is used for non-data frames
2476  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2477  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2478  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2479  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2480  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2481  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2482  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2483  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2484  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2485  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2486  *	by the AP.
2487  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2488  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2489  */
2490 struct ieee80211_sta {
2491 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2492 	u16 aid;
2493 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2494 	bool wme;
2495 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2496 	u8 max_sp;
2497 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2498 	bool tdls;
2499 	bool tdls_initiator;
2500 	bool mfp;
2501 	bool mlo;
2502 	bool spp_amsdu;
2503 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2504 
2505 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2506 
2507 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2508 
2509 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2510 
2511 	u16 valid_links;
2512 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2513 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2514 
2515 	/* must be last */
2516 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2517 };
2518 
2519 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2520 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2521 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2522 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2523 {
2524 	return true;
2525 }
2526 #endif
2527 
2528 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2529 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2530 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2531 
2532 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2533 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2534 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2535 
2536 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2537 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2538 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2539 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2540 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2541 
2542 /**
2543  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2544  *
2545  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2546  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2547  *
2548  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2549  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2550  */
2551 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2552 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2553 };
2554 
2555 /**
2556  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2557  *
2558  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2559  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2560  */
2561 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2562 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2563 };
2564 
2565 /**
2566  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2567  *
2568  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2569  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2570  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2571  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2572  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2573  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2574  *
2575  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2576  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2577  */
2578 struct ieee80211_txq {
2579 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2580 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2581 	u8 tid;
2582 	u8 ac;
2583 
2584 	/* must be last */
2585 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2586 };
2587 
2588 /**
2589  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2590  *
2591  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2592  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2593  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2594  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2595  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2596  *
2597  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2598  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2599  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2600  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2601  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2602  *	algorithm.
2603  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2604  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2605  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2606  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2607  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2608  *	CCK frames.
2609  *
2610  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2611  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2612  *	the FCS at the end.
2613  *
2614  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2615  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2616  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2617  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2618  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2619  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2620  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2621  *
2622  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2623  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2624  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2625  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2626  *
2627  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2628  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2629  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2630  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2631  *
2632  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2633  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2634  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2635  *
2636  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2637  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2638  *
2639  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2640  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2641  *
2642  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2643  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2644  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2645  *
2646  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2647  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2648  *
2649  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2650  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2651  *
2652  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2653  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2654  *	the stack.
2655  *
2656  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2657  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2658  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2659  *
2660  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2661  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2662  *	dtim_period).
2663  *
2664  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2665  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2666  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2667  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2668  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2669  *	only in that case.
2670  *
2671  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2672  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2673  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2674  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2675  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2676  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2677  *
2678  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2679  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2680  *	software.
2681  *
2682  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2683  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2684  *	active interfaces.
2685  *
2686  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2687  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2688  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2689  *
2690  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2691  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2692  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2693  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2694  *	supported cipher suites.
2695  *
2696  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2697  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2698  *	for frames.
2699  *
2700  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2701  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2702  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2703  *	control for more details.
2704  *
2705  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2706  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2707  *
2708  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2709  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2710  *	is supported.
2711  *
2712  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2713  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2714  *
2715  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2716  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2717  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2718  *
2719  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2720  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2721  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2722  *	CSA frame.
2723  *
2724  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2725  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2726  *
2727  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2728  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2729  *
2730  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2731  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2732  *
2733  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2734  *	within A-MPDU.
2735  *
2736  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2737  *	for sent beacons.
2738  *
2739  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2740  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2741  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2742  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2743  *
2744  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2745  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2746  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2747  *	timeout.
2748  *
2749  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2750  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2751  *
2752  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2753  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2754  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2755  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2756  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2757  *
2758  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2759  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2760  *
2761  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2762  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2763  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2764  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2765  *
2766  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2767  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2768  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2769  *
2770  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2771  *	TDLS links.
2772  *
2773  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2774  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2775  *
2776  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2777  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2778  *
2779  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2780  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2781  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2782  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2783  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2784  *
2785  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2786  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2787  *	TXQs to start with.
2788  *
2789  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2790  *	length in tx status information
2791  *
2792  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2793  *
2794  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2795  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2796  *
2797  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2798  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2799  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2800  *
2801  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2802  *	offload
2803  *
2804  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2805  *	offload
2806  *
2807  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2808  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2809  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2810  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2811  *	the stack.
2812  *
2813  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2814  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2815  *
2816  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2817  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2818  *
2819  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2820  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2821  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2822  *	EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2823  *
2824  * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2825  *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2826  *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2827  *	link is switching.
2828  *
2829  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2830  */
2831 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2832 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2833 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2834 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2835 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2836 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2837 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2838 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2839 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2840 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2841 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2842 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2843 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2844 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2845 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2846 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2847 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2848 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2849 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2850 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2851 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2852 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2853 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2854 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2855 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2856 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2857 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2858 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2859 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2860 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2861 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2862 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2863 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2864 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2865 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2866 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2867 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2868 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2869 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2870 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2871 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2872 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2873 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2874 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2875 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2876 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2877 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2878 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2879 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2880 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2881 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2882 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2883 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2884 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2885 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2886 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2887 	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2888 
2889 	/* keep last, obviously */
2890 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2891 };
2892 
2893 /**
2894  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2895  *
2896  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2897  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2898  *
2899  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2900  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2901  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2902  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2903  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2904  *
2905  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2906  *
2907  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2908  *	along with this structure.
2909  *
2910  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2911  *
2912  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2913  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2914  *
2915  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2916  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2917  *
2918  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2919  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2920  *
2921  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2922  *	that HW supports
2923  *
2924  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2925  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2926  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2927  *
2928  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2929  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2930  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2931  *
2932  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2933  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2934  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2935  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2936  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2937  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2938  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2939  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2940  *
2941  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2942  *	can handle.
2943  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2944  *	the hw can report back.
2945  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2946  *
2947  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2948  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2949  *	aggregation.
2950  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2951  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2952  *	it shouldn't be set.
2953  *
2954  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2955  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2956  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2957  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2958  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2959  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2960  *
2961  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2962  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2963  *
2964  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2965  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2966  *
2967  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2968  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2969  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2970  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2971  *
2972  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2973  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2974  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2975  *
2976  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2977  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2978  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2979  *	device_timestamp.
2980  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2981  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2982  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2983  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2984  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2985  *
2986  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2987  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2988  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2989  *
2990  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2991  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2992  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2993  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2994  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2995  *	neither enabled.
2996  *
2997  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2998  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2999  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3000  *
3001  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3002  *	device.
3003  *
3004  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3005  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3006  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3007  *
3008  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3009  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3010  *
3011  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3012  *
3013  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3014  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3015  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3016  *
3017  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3018  */
3019 struct ieee80211_hw {
3020 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3021 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
3022 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3023 	void *priv;
3024 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3025 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3026 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3027 	int vif_data_size;
3028 	int sta_data_size;
3029 	int chanctx_data_size;
3030 	int txq_data_size;
3031 	u16 queues;
3032 	u16 max_listen_interval;
3033 	s8 max_signal;
3034 	u8 max_rates;
3035 	u8 max_report_rates;
3036 	u8 max_rate_tries;
3037 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3038 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3039 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3040 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3041 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3042 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3043 	struct {
3044 		int units_pos;
3045 		s16 accuracy;
3046 	} radiotap_timestamp;
3047 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3048 	u8 uapsd_queues;
3049 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3050 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3051 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3052 	u8 weight_multiplier;
3053 	u32 max_mtu;
3054 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3055 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3056 };
3057 
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3058 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3059 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3060 {
3061 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3062 }
3063 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3064 
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3065 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3066 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3067 {
3068 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3069 }
3070 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3071 
3072 /**
3073  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3074  *
3075  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3076  * @req: cfg80211 request.
3077  */
3078 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3079 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3080 
3081 	/* Keep last */
3082 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3083 };
3084 
3085 /**
3086  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3087  *
3088  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3089  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3090  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3091  * @status: channel-switch response status
3092  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3093  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3094  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3095  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3096  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3097  */
3098 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3099 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3100 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3101 	u8 action_code;
3102 	u32 status;
3103 	u32 timestamp;
3104 	u16 switch_time;
3105 	u16 switch_timeout;
3106 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3107 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3108 };
3109 
3110 /**
3111  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3112  *
3113  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3114  *
3115  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3116  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3117  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3118  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3119  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3120  *
3121  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3122  */
3123 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3124 
3125 /**
3126  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3127  *
3128  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3129  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3130  */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3131 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3132 {
3133 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3134 }
3135 
3136 /**
3137  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3138  *
3139  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3140  * @addr: the address to set
3141  */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3142 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3143 {
3144 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3145 }
3146 
3147 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3148 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3149 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3150 {
3151 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3152 		return NULL;
3153 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3154 }
3155 
3156 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3157 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3158 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3159 {
3160 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3161 		return NULL;
3162 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3163 }
3164 
3165 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3166 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3167 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3168 {
3169 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3170 		return NULL;
3171 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3172 }
3173 
3174 /**
3175  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3176  * @hw: the hardware
3177  * @skb: the skb
3178  *
3179  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3180  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3181  */
3182 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3183 
3184 /**
3185  * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3186  * @hw: the hardware
3187  * @skbs: the skbs
3188  *
3189  * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3190  * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3191  * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3192  * relevant locks to use it.
3193  */
3194 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3195 			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3196 
3197 /**
3198  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3199  *
3200  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3201  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3202  *
3203  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3204  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3205  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3206  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3207  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3208  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3209  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3210  *
3211  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3212  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3213  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3214  *
3215  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3216  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3217  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3218  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3219  *
3220  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3221  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3222  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3223  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3224  *
3225  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3226  *
3227  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3228  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3229  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3230  * based on the receive flags.
3231  *
3232  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3233  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3234  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3235  * keys.
3236  *
3237  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3238  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3239  * handler.
3240  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3241  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3242  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3243  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3244  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3245  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3246  *
3247  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3248  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3249  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3250  *
3251  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3252  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3253  * requirements:
3254  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3255       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3256    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3257       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3258    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3259       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3260       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3261    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3262    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3263  */
3264 
3265 /**
3266  * DOC: Powersave support
3267  *
3268  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3269  *
3270  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3271  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3272  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3273  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3274  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3275  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3276  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3277  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3278  *
3279  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3280  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3281  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3282  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3283  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3284  *
3285  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3286  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3287  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3288  *
3289  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3290  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3291  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3292  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3293  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3294  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3295  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3296  *
3297  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3298  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3299  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3300  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3301  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3302  * periods.
3303  *
3304  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3305  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3306  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3307  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3308  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3309  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3310  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3311  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3312  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3313  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3314  *
3315  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3316  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3317  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3318  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3319  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3320  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3321  *
3322  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3323  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3324  */
3325 
3326 /**
3327  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3328  *
3329  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3330  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3331  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3332  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3333  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3334  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3335  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3336  *
3337  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3338  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3339  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3340  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3341  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3342  *
3343  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3344  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3345  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3346  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3347  *
3348  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3349  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3350  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3351  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3352  *
3353  *  - a list of information element IDs
3354  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3355  *
3356  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3357  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3358  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3359  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3360  * vendor information elements.
3361  *
3362  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3363  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3364  *
3365  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3366  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3367  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3368  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3369  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3370  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3371  *
3372  *
3373  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3374  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3375  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3376  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3377  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3378  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3379  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3380  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3381  *
3382  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3383  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3384  * signal strength threshold checking.
3385  */
3386 
3387 /**
3388  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3389  *
3390  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3391  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3392  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3393  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3394  *
3395  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3396  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3397  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3398  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3399  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3400  * hardware flags.
3401  *
3402  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3403  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3404  * turned off otherwise.
3405  *
3406  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3407  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3408  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3409  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3410  */
3411 
3412 /**
3413  * DOC: Frame filtering
3414  *
3415  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3416  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3417  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3418  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3419  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3420  *
3421  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3422  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3423  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3424  *
3425  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3426  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3427  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3428  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3429  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3430  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3431  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3432  *
3433  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3434  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3435  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3436  * or dropped.
3437  *
3438  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3439  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3440  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3441  * the flag, but not clear it.
3442  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3443  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3444  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3445  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3446  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3447  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3448  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3449  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3450  */
3451 
3452 /**
3453  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3454  *
3455  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3456  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3457  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3458  *
3459  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3460  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3461  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3462  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3463  * the driver code.
3464  *
3465  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3466  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3467  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3468  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3469  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3470  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3471  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3472  *
3473  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3474  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3475  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3476  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3477  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3478  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3479  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3480  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3481  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3482  * @sta_notify callback.
3483  *
3484  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3485  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3486  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3487  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3488  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3489  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3490  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3491  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3492  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3493  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3494  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3495  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3496  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3497  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3498  *
3499  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3500  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3501  *
3502  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3503  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3504  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3505  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3506  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3507  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3508  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3509  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3510  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3511  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3512  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3513  *
3514  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3515  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3516  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3517  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3518  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3519  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3520  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3521  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3522  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3523  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3524  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3525  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3526  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3527  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3528  *
3529  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3530  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3531  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3532  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3533  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3534  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3535  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3536  *
3537  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3538  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3539  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3540  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3541  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3542  *
3543  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3544  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3545  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3546  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3547  */
3548 
3549 /**
3550  * DOC: HW queue control
3551  *
3552  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3553  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3554  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3555  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3556  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3557  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3558  *
3559  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3560  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3561  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3562  *
3563  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3564  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3565  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3566  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3567  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3568  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3569  * the hardware queue.
3570  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3571  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3572  *
3573  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3574  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3575  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3576  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3577  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3578  *
3579  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3580  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3581  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3582  * off-channel queue:         9
3583  *
3584  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3585  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3586  *
3587  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3588  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3589  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3590  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3591  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3592  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3593  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3594  *
3595  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3596  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3597  *
3598  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3599  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3600  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3601  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3602  */
3603 
3604 /**
3605  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3606  *
3607  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3608  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3609  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3610  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3611  *
3612  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3613  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3614  *	multicast address.
3615  *
3616  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3617  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3618  *
3619  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3620  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3621  *
3622  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3623  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3624  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3625  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3626  *	honour this flag if possible.
3627  *
3628  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3629  *	station
3630  *
3631  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3632  *
3633  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3634  *
3635  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3636  *
3637  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3638  */
3639 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3640 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3641 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3642 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3643 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3644 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3645 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3646 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3647 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3648 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3649 };
3650 
3651 /**
3652  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3653  *
3654  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3655  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3656  *
3657  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3658  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3659  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3660  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3661  *
3662  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3663  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3664  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3665  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3666  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3667  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3668  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3669  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3670  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3671  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3672  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3673  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3674  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3675  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3676  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3677  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3678  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3679  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3680  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3681  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3682  */
3683 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3684 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3685 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3686 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3687 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3688 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3689 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3690 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3691 };
3692 
3693 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3694 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3695 
3696 /**
3697  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3698  *
3699  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3700  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3701  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3702  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3703  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3704  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3705  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3706  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3707  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3708  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3709  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3710  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3711  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3712  */
3713 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3714 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3715 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3716 	u16 tid;
3717 	u16 ssn;
3718 	u16 buf_size;
3719 	bool amsdu;
3720 	u16 timeout;
3721 };
3722 
3723 /**
3724  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3725  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3726  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3727  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3728  */
3729 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3730 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3731 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3732 };
3733 
3734 /**
3735  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3736  *
3737  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3738  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3739  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3740  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3741  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3742  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3743  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3744  *	the peer.
3745  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3746  *	by the peer
3747  */
3748 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3749 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3750 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3751 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3752 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3753 };
3754 
3755 /**
3756  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3757  *
3758  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3759  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3760  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3761  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3762  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3763  *
3764  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3765  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3766  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3767  */
3768 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3769 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3770 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3771 };
3772 
3773 /**
3774  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3775  *
3776  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3777  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3778  *
3779  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3780  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3781  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3782  *	of wowlan configuration)
3783  */
3784 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3785 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3786 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3787 };
3788 
3789 /**
3790  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3791  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3792  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3793  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3794  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3795  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3796  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3797  * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3798  *	while just having been associated
3799  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3800  *	Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3801  */
3802 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3803 	u16 duration;
3804 	u16 subtype;
3805 	u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3806 	int link_id;
3807 };
3808 
3809 /**
3810  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3811  *
3812  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3813  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3814  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3815  *
3816  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3817  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3818  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3819  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3820  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3821  *	Must be atomic.
3822  *
3823  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3824  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3825  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3826  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3827  *	or zero.
3828  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3829  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3830  *	is added.
3831  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3832  *
3833  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3834  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3835  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3836  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3837  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3838  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3839  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3840  *
3841  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3842  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3843  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3844  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3845  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3846  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3847  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3848  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3849  *	must return 1 from this function.
3850  *
3851  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3852  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3853  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3854  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3855  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3856  *
3857  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3858  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3859  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3860  *	in suspend().
3861  *
3862  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3863  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3864  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3865  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3866  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3867  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3868  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3869  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3870  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3871  *
3872  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3873  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3874  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3875  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3876  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3877  *
3878  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3879  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3880  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3881  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3882  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3883  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3884  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3885  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3886  *
3887  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3888  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3889  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3890  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3891  *
3892  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3893  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3894  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3895  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3896  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3897  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3898  *	can sleep.
3899  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3900  *	are not implemented.
3901  *
3902  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3903  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3904  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3905  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3906  *	The callback can sleep.
3907  *
3908  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3909  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3910  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3911  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3912  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3913  *	non-MLO connections.
3914  *	The callback can sleep.
3915  *
3916  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3917  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3918  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3919  *
3920  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3921  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3922  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3923  *
3924  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3925  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3926  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3927  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3928  *	which flags are changed.
3929  *	This callback can sleep.
3930  *
3931  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3932  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3933  *
3934  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3935  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3936  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3937  *	is enabled.
3938  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3939  *	The callback can sleep.
3940  *
3941  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3942  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3943  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3944  *	The callback must be atomic.
3945  *
3946  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3947  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3948  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3949  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3950  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3951  *
3952  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3953  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3954  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3955  *
3956  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3957  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3958  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3959  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3960  *	that power save is disabled.
3961  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3962  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3963  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3964  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3965  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3966  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3967  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3968  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3969  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3970  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3971  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3972  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3973  *	The callback can sleep.
3974  *
3975  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3976  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3977  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3978  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3979  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3980  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3981  *	The callback can sleep.
3982  *
3983  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3984  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3985  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3986  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3987  *
3988  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3989  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3990  *
3991  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3992  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3993  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3994  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3995  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3996  *
3997  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3998  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3999  *	this notification.
4000  *	The callback can sleep.
4001  *
4002  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4003  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
4004  *	The callback can sleep.
4005  *
4006  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4007  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4008  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4009  *	The callback must be atomic.
4010  *
4011  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4012  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4013  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4014  *	should be set as well.
4015  *	The callback can sleep.
4016  *
4017  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4018  *	The callback can sleep.
4019  *
4020  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4021  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4022  *
4023  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4024  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4025  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4026  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4027  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4028  *	This callback can sleep.
4029  *
4030  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4031  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4032  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4033  *
4034  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4035  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4036  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4037  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4038  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4039  *
4040  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4041  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4042  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4043  *	callback can sleep.
4044  *
4045  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4046  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4047  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4048  *	callback can sleep.
4049  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4050  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4051  *
4052  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4053  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4054  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4055  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4056  *
4057  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4058  *	power for the station.
4059  *	This callback can sleep.
4060  *
4061  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4062  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4063  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4064  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4065  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4066  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4067  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4068  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4069  *	The callback can sleep.
4070  *
4071  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4072  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4073  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4074  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4075  *	in @sta_state.
4076  *	The callback can sleep.
4077  *
4078  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
4079  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4080  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4081  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4082  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4083  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4084  *	Must be atomic.
4085  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4086  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4087  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4088  *
4089  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4090  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4091  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4092  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4093  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4094  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4095  *	The callback can sleep.
4096  *
4097  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4098  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4099  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4100  *	The callback can sleep.
4101  *
4102  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4103  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4104  *	required function.
4105  *	The callback can sleep.
4106  *
4107  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4108  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4109  *	required function.
4110  *	The callback can sleep.
4111  *
4112  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4113  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4114  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4115  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4116  *	The callback can sleep.
4117  *
4118  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4119  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4120  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4121  *	TSF synchronization.
4122  *	The callback can sleep.
4123  *
4124  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4125  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4126  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4127  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4128  *	The callback can sleep.
4129  *
4130  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4131  *
4132  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4133  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4134  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4135  *	The callback can sleep.
4136  *
4137  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4138  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4139  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4140  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4141  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4142  *
4143  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4144  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4145  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4146  *
4147  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4148  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4149  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4150  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4151  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4152  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4153  *	The callback can sleep.
4154  *
4155  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4156  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4157  *	The callback can sleep.
4158  *
4159  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4160  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4161  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4162  *	completion of the channel switch.
4163  *
4164  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4165  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4166  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4167  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4168  *
4169  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4170  *
4171  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4172  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4173  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4174  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4175  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4176  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4177  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4178  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4179  *	must be accepted in this case.
4180  *	This callback may sleep.
4181  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4182  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4183  *
4184  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4185  *
4186  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4187  *
4188  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4189  *	queues before entering power save.
4190  *
4191  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4192  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4193  *	The callback can sleep.
4194  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4195  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4196  *	The callback must be atomic.
4197  *
4198  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4199  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4200  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4201  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4202  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4203  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4204  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4205  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4206  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4207  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4208  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4209  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4210  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4211  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4212  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4213  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4214  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4215  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4216  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4217  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4218  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4219  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4220  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4221  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4222  *	This callback must be atomic.
4223  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4224  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4225  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4226  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4227  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4228  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4229  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4230  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4231  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4232  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4233  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4234  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4235  *	This callback must be atomic.
4236  *
4237  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4238  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4239  *	expected to return a static value.
4240  *
4241  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4242  *
4243  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4244  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4245  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4246  *	expected to return a static value.
4247  *
4248  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4249  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4250  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4251  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4252  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4253  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4254  *	management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4255  *	to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4256  *	able to synchronize with the GO.
4257  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4258  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4259  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4260  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4261  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4262  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4263  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4264  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4265  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4266  *
4267  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4268  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4269  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4270  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4271  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4272  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4273  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4274  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4275  *
4276  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4277  *	This callback may sleep.
4278  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4279  *	This callback may sleep.
4280  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4281  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4282  *	channel context with different settings
4283  *	This callback may sleep.
4284  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4285  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4286  *	This callback may sleep.
4287  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4288  *	unbound from vif.
4289  *	This callback may sleep.
4290  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4291  *	another, as specified in the list of
4292  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4293  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4294  *	This callback may sleep.
4295  *
4296  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4297  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4298  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4299  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4300  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4301  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4302  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4303  *
4304  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4305  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4306  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4307  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4308  *	This callback may sleep.
4309  *
4310  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4311  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4312  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4313  *
4314  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4315  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4316  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4317  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4318  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4319  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4320  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4321  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4322  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4323  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4324  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4325  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4326  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4327  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4328  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4329  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4330  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4331  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4332  *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4333  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4334  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4335  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4336  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4337  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4338  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4339  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4340  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4341  *
4342  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4343  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4344  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4345  *
4346  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4347  *	and hardware limits.
4348  *
4349  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4350  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4351  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4352  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4353  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4354  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4355  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4356  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4357  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4358  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4359  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4360  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4361  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4362  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4363  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4364  *	the function call.
4365  *
4366  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4367  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4368  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4369  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4370  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4371  *
4372  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4373  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4374  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4375  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4376  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4377  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4378  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4379  *	changed parameters.
4380  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4381  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4382  *	this call.
4383  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4384  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4385  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4386  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4387  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4388  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4389  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4390  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4391  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4392  *
4393  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4394  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4395  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4396  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4397  *	This callback may sleep.
4398  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4399  *	This callback may sleep.
4400  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4401  *	4-address mode
4402  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4403  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4404  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4405  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4406  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4407  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4408  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4409  *	twt structure.
4410  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4411  *	from the peer.
4412  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4413  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4414  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4415  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4416  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4417  *	radar channel.
4418  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4419  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4420  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4421  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4422  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4423  *	supported by the driver.
4424  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4425  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4426  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4427  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4428  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4429  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4430  *	This callback can sleep.
4431  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4432  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4433  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4434  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4435  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4436  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4437  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4438  *	that.
4439  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4440  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4441  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4442  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4443  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4444  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4445  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4446  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4447  */
4448 struct ieee80211_ops {
4449 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4450 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4451 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4452 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4453 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4454 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4455 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4456 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4457 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4458 #endif
4459 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4461 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4462 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4463 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4464 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4466 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4467 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4469 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4470 				 u64 changed);
4471 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4472 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4473 				u64 changed);
4474 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4475 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4476 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4477 				  u64 changed);
4478 
4479 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4480 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4481 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4482 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4483 
4484 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4485 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4486 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4488 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4489 				 u64 multicast);
4490 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4492 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4493 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4494 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4495 		       bool set);
4496 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4497 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4498 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4499 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4500 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4501 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4502 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4503 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4504 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4505 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4507 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4508 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4509 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4510 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4511 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4513 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4515 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4516 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4517 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4518 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4519 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4520 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4521 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4522 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4524 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4525 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4526 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4528 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4529 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4530 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4531 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4532 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4533 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4535 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4536 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4537 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4538 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4539 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4540 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4541 				 struct dentry *dir);
4542 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4545 				struct dentry *dir);
4546 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4548 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4549 				     struct dentry *dir);
4550 #endif
4551 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4552 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4553 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4554 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4555 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4556 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4557 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4558 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4559 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4560 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4562 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4563 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4565 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4566 			      u32 changed);
4567 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4569 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4570 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4571 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4572 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4573 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4574 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4575 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4577 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4578 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4579 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580 			u64 tsf);
4581 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582 			   s64 offset);
4583 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4584 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4585 
4586 	/**
4587 	 * @ampdu_action:
4588 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4589 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4590 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4591 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4592 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4593 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4594 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4595 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4596 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4597 	 *
4598 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4599 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4600 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4601 	 *
4602 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4603 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4604 	 *
4605 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4606 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4607 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4608 	 *
4609 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4610 	 *
4611 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4612 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4613 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4614 	 *
4615 	 * The callback can sleep.
4616 	 */
4617 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4619 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4620 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4621 		struct survey_info *survey);
4622 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4623 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4624 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4625 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4626 			    void *data, int len);
4627 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4628 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4629 			     void *data, int len);
4630 #endif
4631 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4632 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4633 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4634 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4635 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4636 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4637 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4638 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4639 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4640 
4641 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4644 				 int duration,
4645 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4646 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4647 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4648 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4649 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4650 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4651 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4652 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4653 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4654 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4655 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4657 
4658 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4659 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4660 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4661 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4662 				      bool more_data);
4663 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4664 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4665 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4666 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4667 					bool more_data);
4668 
4669 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4670 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4671 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4672 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4673 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4674 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4675 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4676 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4677 
4678 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4680 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4681 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4682 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4683 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4684 
4685 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4686 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4687 					     unsigned int link_id);
4688 
4689 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4691 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4692 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4693 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4694 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4695 			       u32 changed);
4696 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4697 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4698 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4699 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4700 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4701 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4702 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4703 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4704 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4705 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4706 				  int n_vifs,
4707 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4708 
4709 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4710 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4711 
4712 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4713 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4715 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4716 #endif
4717 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4719 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4720 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4723 
4724 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4727 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4728 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4729 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4730 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4732 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4733 
4734 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4735 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4736 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4737 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4738 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4739 			   int *dbm);
4740 
4741 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4742 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4743 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4744 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4745 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4746 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4747 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4748 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4749 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4750 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4751 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4752 
4753 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4754 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4755 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4756 
4757 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4758 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4759 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4760 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4761 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4762 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4764 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4765 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4767 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4768 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4769 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4770 			    u8 instance_id);
4771 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4772 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4773 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4774 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4775 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4776 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4777 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4778 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4779 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4780 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4781 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4782 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4783 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4784 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4785 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4786 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4787 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4788 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4789 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4790 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4791 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4792 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4793 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4794 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4795 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4796 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4797 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4798 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4799 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4800 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4801 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4802 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4803 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4804 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4805 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4806 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4807 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4808 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4809 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4811 				   u16 active_links);
4812 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4814 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4815 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4816 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4818 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4819 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4820 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4821 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4823 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4825 			    struct net_device *dev,
4826 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4827 			    void *type_data);
4828 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4829 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4830 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4831 };
4832 
4833 /**
4834  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4835  *
4836  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4837  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4838  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4839  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4840  * @priv_data_len.
4841  *
4842  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4843  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4844  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4845  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4846  *
4847  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4848  */
4849 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4850 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4851 					   const char *requested_name);
4852 
4853 /**
4854  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4855  *
4856  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4857  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4858  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4859  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4860  * @priv_data_len.
4861  *
4862  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4863  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4864  *
4865  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4866  */
4867 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4868 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4869 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4870 {
4871 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4872 }
4873 
4874 /**
4875  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4876  *
4877  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4878  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4879  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4880  *
4881  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4882  *
4883  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4884  */
4885 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4886 
4887 /**
4888  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4889  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4890  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4891  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4892  */
4893 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4894 	int throughput;
4895 	int blink_time;
4896 };
4897 
4898 /**
4899  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4900  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4901  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4902  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4903  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4904  */
4905 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4906 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4907 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4908 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4909 };
4910 
4911 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4912 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4913 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4914 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4915 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4916 const char *
4917 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4918 				   unsigned int flags,
4919 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4920 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4921 #endif
4922 /**
4923  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4924  *
4925  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4926  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4927  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4928  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4929  *
4930  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4931  *
4932  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4933  */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4934 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4935 {
4936 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4937 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4938 #else
4939 	return NULL;
4940 #endif
4941 }
4942 
4943 /**
4944  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4945  *
4946  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4947  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4948  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4949  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4950  *
4951  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4952  *
4953  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4954  */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4955 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4956 {
4957 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4958 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4959 #else
4960 	return NULL;
4961 #endif
4962 }
4963 
4964 /**
4965  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4966  *
4967  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4968  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4969  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4970  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4971  *
4972  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4973  *
4974  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4975  */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4976 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4977 {
4978 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4979 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4980 #else
4981 	return NULL;
4982 #endif
4983 }
4984 
4985 /**
4986  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4987  *
4988  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4989  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4990  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4991  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4992  *
4993  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4994  *
4995  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4996  */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4997 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4998 {
4999 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5000 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5001 #else
5002 	return NULL;
5003 #endif
5004 }
5005 
5006 /**
5007  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5008  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5009  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5010  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5011  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5012  *
5013  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5014  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5015  *
5016  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5017  */
5018 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5019 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5020 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5021 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5022 {
5023 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5024 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5025 						  blink_table_len);
5026 #else
5027 	return NULL;
5028 #endif
5029 }
5030 
5031 /**
5032  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5033  *
5034  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5035  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5036  *
5037  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5038  */
5039 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5040 
5041 /**
5042  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5043  *
5044  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5045  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5046  * before calling this function.
5047  *
5048  * @hw: the hardware to free
5049  */
5050 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5051 
5052 /**
5053  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5054  *
5055  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5056  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5057  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5058  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5059  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5060  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5061  *
5062  * @hw: the hardware to restart
5063  */
5064 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5065 
5066 /**
5067  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5068  *
5069  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5070  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5071  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5072  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5073  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5074  *
5075  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5076  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5077  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5078  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5079  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5080  *
5081  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5082  *
5083  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5084  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5085  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5086  * @list: the destination list
5087  */
5088 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5089 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5090 
5091 /**
5092  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5093  *
5094  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5095  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5096  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5097  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5098  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5099  *
5100  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5101  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5102  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5103  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5104  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5105  *
5106  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5107  *
5108  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5109  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5110  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5111  * @napi: the NAPI context
5112  */
5113 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5114 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5115 
5116 /**
5117  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5118  *
5119  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5120  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5121  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5122  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5123  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5124  *
5125  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5126  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5127  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5128  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5129  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5130  *
5131  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5132  *
5133  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5134  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5135  */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5136 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5137 {
5138 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5139 }
5140 
5141 /**
5142  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5143  *
5144  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5145  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5146  *
5147  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5148  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5149  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5150  *
5151  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5152  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5153  */
5154 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5155 
5156 /**
5157  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5158  *
5159  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5160  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5161  *
5162  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5163  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5164  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5165  *
5166  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5167  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5168  */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5169 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5170 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5171 {
5172 	local_bh_disable();
5173 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5174 	local_bh_enable();
5175 }
5176 
5177 /**
5178  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5179  *
5180  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5181  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5182  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5183  *
5184  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5185  *
5186  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5187  * each other.
5188  *
5189  * @sta: currently connected sta
5190  * @start: start or stop PS
5191  *
5192  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5193  */
5194 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5195 
5196 /**
5197  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5198  *                                  (in process context)
5199  *
5200  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5201  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5202  * applies.
5203  *
5204  * @sta: currently connected sta
5205  * @start: start or stop PS
5206  *
5207  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5208  */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5209 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5210 						  bool start)
5211 {
5212 	int ret;
5213 
5214 	local_bh_disable();
5215 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5216 	local_bh_enable();
5217 
5218 	return ret;
5219 }
5220 
5221 /**
5222  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5223  * @sta: currently connected station
5224  *
5225  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5226  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5227  * connected station was received.
5228  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5229  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5230  * be serialized.
5231  */
5232 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5233 
5234 /**
5235  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5236  * @sta: currently connected station
5237  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5238  *
5239  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5240  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5241  * from a connected station was received.
5242  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5243  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5244  * serialized.
5245  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5246  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5247  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5248  * checks.
5249  */
5250 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5251 
5252 /*
5253  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5254  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5255  */
5256 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5257 
5258 /**
5259  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5260  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5261  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5262  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5263  *
5264  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5265  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5266  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5267  *
5268  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5269  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5270  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5271  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5272  *
5273  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5274  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5275  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5276  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5277  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5278  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5279  *
5280  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5281  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5282  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5283  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5284  * use this API.
5285  */
5286 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5287 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5288 
5289 /**
5290  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5291  *
5292  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5293  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5294  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5295  *
5296  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5297  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5298  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5299  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5300  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5301  */
5302 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5303 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5304 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5305 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5306 			    int max_rates);
5307 
5308 /**
5309  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5310  *
5311  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5312  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5313  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5314  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5315  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5316  * slow stations to starve).
5317  *
5318  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5319  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5320  */
5321 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5322 					   u32 thr);
5323 
5324 /**
5325  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5326  *
5327  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5328  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5329  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5330  *
5331  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5332  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5333  * @info: tx status information
5334  */
5335 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5336 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5337 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5338 
5339 /**
5340  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5341  *
5342  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5343  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5344  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5345  *
5346  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5347  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5348  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5349  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5350  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5351  *
5352  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5353  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5354  */
5355 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5356 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5357 
5358 /**
5359  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5360  *
5361  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5362  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5363  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5364  *
5365  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5366  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5367  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5368  *
5369  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5370  * @status: tx status information
5371  */
5372 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5373 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5374 
5375 /**
5376  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5377  *
5378  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5379  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5380  * specific skbs.
5381  *
5382  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5383  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5384  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5385  *
5386  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5387  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5388  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5389  * @info: tx status information
5390  */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5391 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5392 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5393 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5394 {
5395 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5396 		.sta = sta,
5397 		.info = info,
5398 	};
5399 
5400 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5401 }
5402 
5403 /**
5404  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5405  *
5406  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5407  *
5408  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5409  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5410  * for a single hardware.
5411  *
5412  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5413  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5414  */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5415 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5416 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5417 {
5418 	local_bh_disable();
5419 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5420 	local_bh_enable();
5421 }
5422 
5423 /**
5424  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5425  *
5426  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5427  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5428  *
5429  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5430  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5431  *
5432  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5433  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5434  */
5435 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5436 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5437 
5438 /**
5439  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5440  *
5441  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5442  * connected STA.
5443  *
5444  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5445  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5446  */
5447 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5448 
5449 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5450 
5451 /**
5452  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5453  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5454  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5455  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5456  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5457  *	should be ignored.
5458  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5459  */
5460 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5461 	u16 tim_offset;
5462 	u16 tim_length;
5463 
5464 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5465 	u16 mbssid_off;
5466 };
5467 
5468 /**
5469  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5470  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5471  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5472  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5473  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5474  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5475  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5476  *
5477  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5478  * obtain the beacon template.
5479  *
5480  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5481  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5482  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5483  * applicable, the CSA count.
5484  *
5485  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5486  *
5487  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5488  */
5489 struct sk_buff *
5490 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5491 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5492 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5493 			      unsigned int link_id);
5494 
5495 /**
5496  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5497  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5498  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5499  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5500  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5501  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5502  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5503  *
5504  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5505  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5506  * requested index.
5507  *
5508  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5509  */
5510 struct sk_buff *
5511 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5512 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5513 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5514 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5515 
5516 /**
5517  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5518  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5519  *
5520  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5521  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5522  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5523  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5524  */
5525 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5526 	u8 cnt;
5527 	struct {
5528 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5529 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5530 	} bcn[];
5531 };
5532 
5533 /**
5534  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5535  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5536  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5537  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5538  *
5539  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5540  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5541  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5542  * one multiple BSSID element.
5543  *
5544  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5545  *
5546  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5547  *	%NULL on error.
5548  */
5549 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5550 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5551 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5552 				       unsigned int link_id);
5553 
5554 /**
5555  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5556  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5557  *
5558  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5559  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5560  */
5561 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5562 
5563 /**
5564  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5565  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5566  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5567  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5568  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5569  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5570  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5571  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5572  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5573  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5574  *
5575  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5576  * obtain the beacon frame.
5577  *
5578  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5579  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5580  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5581  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5582  *
5583  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5584  *
5585  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5586  */
5587 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5588 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5589 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5590 					 unsigned int link_id);
5591 
5592 /**
5593  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5594  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5595  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5596  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5597  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5598  *
5599  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5600  *
5601  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5602  */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5603 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5604 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5605 						   unsigned int link_id)
5606 {
5607 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5608 }
5609 
5610 /**
5611  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5612  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5613  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5614  *
5615  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5616  * This function is called implicitly when
5617  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5618  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5619  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5620  *
5621  * Return: new countdown value
5622  */
5623 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5624 				  unsigned int link_id);
5625 
5626 /**
5627  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5628  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5629  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5630  *
5631  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5632  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5633  *
5634  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5635  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5636  */
5637 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5638 
5639 /**
5640  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5641  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5642  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5643  *
5644  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5645  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5646  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5647  */
5648 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5649 
5650 /**
5651  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5652  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5653  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5654  *
5655  * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5656  */
5657 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5658 					 unsigned int link_id);
5659 
5660 /**
5661  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5662  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5663  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5664  *
5665  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5666  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5667  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5668  */
5669 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5670 
5671 /**
5672  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5673  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5674  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5675  *
5676  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5677  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5678  *
5679  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5680  *
5681  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5682  */
5683 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5684 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5685 
5686 /**
5687  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5688  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5689  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5690  *
5691  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5692  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5693  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5694  *
5695  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5696  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5697  *
5698  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5699  */
5700 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5701 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5702 
5703 /**
5704  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5705  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5706  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5707  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5708  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5709  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5710  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5711  *	if at all possible
5712  *
5713  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5714  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5715  * BSSID and address is used.
5716  *
5717  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5718  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5719  *
5720  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5721  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5722  *
5723  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5724  */
5725 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5726 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5727 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5728 
5729 /**
5730  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5731  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5732  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5733  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5734  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5735  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5736  *
5737  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5738  * hardware.
5739  *
5740  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5741  */
5742 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5743 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5744 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5745 				       size_t tailroom);
5746 
5747 /**
5748  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5749  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5750  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5751  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5752  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5753  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5754  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5755  *
5756  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5757  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5758  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5759  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5760  */
5761 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5762 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5763 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5764 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5765 
5766 /**
5767  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5768  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5769  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5770  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5771  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5772  *
5773  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5774  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5775  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5776  *
5777  * Return: The duration.
5778  */
5779 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5780 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5781 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5782 
5783 /**
5784  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5785  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5786  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5787  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5788  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5789  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5790  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5791  *
5792  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5793  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5794  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5795  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5796  */
5797 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5798 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5799 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5800 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5801 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5802 
5803 /**
5804  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5805  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5806  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5807  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5808  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5809  *
5810  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5811  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5812  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5813  *
5814  * Return: The duration.
5815  */
5816 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5817 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5818 				    size_t frame_len,
5819 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5820 
5821 /**
5822  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5823  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5824  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5825  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5826  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5827  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5828  *
5829  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5830  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5831  *
5832  * Return: The duration.
5833  */
5834 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5835 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5836 					enum nl80211_band band,
5837 					size_t frame_len,
5838 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5839 
5840 /**
5841  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5842  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5843  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5844  *
5845  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5846  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5847  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5848  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5849  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5850  *
5851  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5852  * frames are available.
5853  *
5854  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5855  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5856  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5857  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5858  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5859  * use common code for all beacons.
5860  */
5861 struct sk_buff *
5862 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5863 
5864 /**
5865  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5866  *
5867  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5868  *
5869  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5870  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5871  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5872  */
5873 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5874 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5875 
5876 /**
5877  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5878  *
5879  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5880  * from the given packet.
5881  *
5882  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5883  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5884  *	with this P1K
5885  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5886  */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5887 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5888 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5889 {
5890 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5891 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5892 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5893 
5894 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5895 }
5896 
5897 /**
5898  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5899  *
5900  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5901  * and transmitter address.
5902  *
5903  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5904  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5905  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5906  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5907  */
5908 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5909 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5910 
5911 /**
5912  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5913  *
5914  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5915  * in the packet.
5916  *
5917  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5918  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5919  *	encrypted with this key
5920  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5921  */
5922 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5923 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5924 
5925 /**
5926  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5927  *
5928  * @pos: start of crypto header
5929  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5930  * @pn: PN to add
5931  *
5932  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5933  * the packet payload)
5934  *
5935  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5936  * point to the crypto header)
5937  */
5938 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5939 
5940 /**
5941  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5942  *
5943  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5944  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5945  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5946  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5947  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5948  *
5949  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5950  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5951  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5952  *
5953  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5954  * can be done concurrently.
5955  */
5956 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5957 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5958 
5959 /**
5960  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5961  *
5962  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5963  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5964  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5965  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5966  * @seq: new sequence data
5967  *
5968  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5969  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5970  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5971  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5972  *
5973  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5974  * can be done concurrently.
5975  */
5976 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5977 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5978 
5979 /**
5980  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5981  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5982  *
5983  * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5984  *
5985  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5986  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5987  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5988  */
5989 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5990 
5991 /**
5992  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5993  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5994  * @keyconf: new key data
5995  * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
5996  *
5997  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5998  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5999  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6000  *
6001  * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6002  * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6003  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6004  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6005  *
6006  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6007  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6008  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6009  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6010  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6011  * of the reconfiguration.
6012  *
6013  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6014  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6015  *
6016  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6017  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6018  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6019  * the key that's being replaced.
6020  */
6021 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6022 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6023 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6024 			int link_id);
6025 
6026 /**
6027  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6028  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6029  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6030  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6031  * @gfp: allocation flags
6032  */
6033 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6034 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6035 
6036 /**
6037  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6038  *
6039  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6040  * at the same time.
6041  *
6042  * @keyconf: the key in question
6043  */
6044 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6045 
6046 /**
6047  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6048  *
6049  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6050  * at the same time.
6051  *
6052  * @keyconf: the key in question
6053  */
6054 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6055 
6056 /**
6057  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6058  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6059  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6060  *
6061  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6062  */
6063 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6064 
6065 /**
6066  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6067  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6068  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6069  *
6070  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6071  */
6072 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6073 
6074 /**
6075  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6076  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6077  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6078  *
6079  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6080  *
6081  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6082  */
6083 
6084 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6085 
6086 /**
6087  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6088  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6089  *
6090  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6091  */
6092 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6093 
6094 /**
6095  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6096  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6097  *
6098  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6099  */
6100 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6101 
6102 /**
6103  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6104  *
6105  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6106  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6107  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6108  * any context, including hardirq context.
6109  *
6110  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6111  * @info: information about the completed scan
6112  */
6113 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6114 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6115 
6116 /**
6117  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6118  *
6119  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6120  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6121  *
6122  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6123  */
6124 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6125 
6126 /**
6127  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6128  *
6129  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6130  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6131  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6132  * while associating, for instance.
6133  *
6134  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6135  */
6136 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6137 
6138 /**
6139  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6140  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6141  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6142  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6143  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6144  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6145  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6146  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6147  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6148  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6149  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6150  *	for instance.
6151  */
6152 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6153 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6154 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6155 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6156 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6157 };
6158 
6159 /**
6160  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6161  *
6162  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6163  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6164  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6165  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6166  *
6167  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6168  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6169  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6170  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6171  */
6172 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6173 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6174 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6175 				  void *data);
6176 
6177 /**
6178  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6179  *
6180  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6181  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6182  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6183  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6184  * be used.
6185  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6186  *
6187  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6188  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6189  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6190  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6191  */
6192 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6193 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6194 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6195 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6196 				    void *data)
6197 {
6198 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6199 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6200 				     iterator, data);
6201 }
6202 
6203 /**
6204  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6205  *
6206  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6207  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6208  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6209  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6210  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6211  *
6212  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6213  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6214  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6215  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6216  */
6217 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6218 						u32 iter_flags,
6219 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6220 						    u8 *mac,
6221 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6222 						void *data);
6223 
6224 /**
6225  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6226  *
6227  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6228  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6229  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6230  *
6231  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6232  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6233  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6234  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6235  */
6236 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6237 					     u32 iter_flags,
6238 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6239 						u8 *mac,
6240 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6241 					     void *data);
6242 
6243 /**
6244  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6245  *
6246  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6247  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6248  * function for them.
6249  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6250  *
6251  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6252  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6253  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6254  */
6255 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6256 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6257 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6258 				       void *data);
6259 
6260 /**
6261  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6262  *
6263  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6264  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6265  * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6266  * mutex.
6267  *
6268  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6269  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6270  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6271  */
6272 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6273 				    void (*iterator)(void *data,
6274 						     struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6275 				    void *data);
6276 
6277 /**
6278  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6279  *
6280  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6281  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6282  *
6283  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6284  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6285  */
6286 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6287 
6288 /**
6289  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6290  *
6291  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6292  * workqueue.
6293  *
6294  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6295  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6296  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6297  */
6298 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6299 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6300 				  unsigned long delay);
6301 
6302 /**
6303  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6304  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6305  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6306  *
6307  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6308  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6309  * mac80211.
6310  *
6311  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6312  */
6313 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6314 					    u16 tid);
6315 
6316 /**
6317  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6318  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6319  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6320  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6321  *
6322  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6323  *
6324  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6325  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6326  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6327  */
6328 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6329 				  u16 timeout);
6330 
6331 /**
6332  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6333  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6334  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6335  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6336  *
6337  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6338  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6339  * from any context.
6340  */
6341 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6342 				      u16 tid);
6343 
6344 /**
6345  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6346  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6347  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6348  *
6349  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6350  *
6351  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6352  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6353  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6354  */
6355 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6356 
6357 /**
6358  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6359  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6360  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6361  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6362  *
6363  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6364  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6365  * can be called from any context.
6366  */
6367 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6368 				     u16 tid);
6369 
6370 /**
6371  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6372  *
6373  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6374  * @addr: station's address
6375  *
6376  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6377  *
6378  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6379  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6380  */
6381 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6382 					 const u8 *addr);
6383 
6384 /**
6385  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6386  *
6387  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6388  * @addr: remote station's address
6389  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6390  *
6391  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6392  *
6393  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6394  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6395  *
6396  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6397  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6398  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6399  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6400  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6401  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6402  *      is not reliable.
6403  *
6404  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6405  */
6406 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6407 					       const u8 *addr,
6408 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6409 
6410 /**
6411  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6412  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6413  * @addr: remote station's link address
6414  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6415  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6416  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6417  *
6418  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6419  *
6420  * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6421  */
6422 struct ieee80211_sta *
6423 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6424 				 const u8 *addr,
6425 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6426 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6427 
6428 /**
6429  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6430  * @hw: the hardware
6431  * @pubsta: the station
6432  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6433  *
6434  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6435  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6436  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6437  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6438  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6439  *
6440  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6441  * manner.
6442  *
6443  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6444  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6445  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6446  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6447  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6448  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6449  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6450  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6451  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6452  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6453  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6454  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6455  * woke up while blocked or not.
6456  */
6457 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6458 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6459 
6460 /**
6461  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6462  * @pubsta: the station
6463  *
6464  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6465  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6466  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6467  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6468  *
6469  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6470  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6471  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6472  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6473  *
6474  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6475  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6476  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6477  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6478  */
6479 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6480 
6481 /**
6482  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6483  * @pubsta: the station
6484  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6485  *
6486  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6487  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6488  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6489  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6490  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6491  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6492  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6493  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6494  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6495  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6496  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6497  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6498  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6499  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6500  */
6501 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6502 
6503 /**
6504  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6505  * @pubsta: the station
6506  *
6507  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6508  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6509  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6510  *
6511  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6512  * there is no need to call this function.
6513  */
6514 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6515 
6516 /**
6517  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6518  *
6519  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6520  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6521  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6522  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6523  *
6524  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6525  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6526  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6527  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6528  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6529  * attempts.
6530  *
6531  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6532  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6533  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6534  * them to 0.
6535  *
6536  * @pubsta: the station
6537  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6538  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6539  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6540  */
6541 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6542 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6543 
6544 /**
6545  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6546  *
6547  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6548  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6549  *
6550  * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6551  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6552  */
6553 bool
6554 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6555 
6556 /**
6557  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6558  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6559  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6560  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6561  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6562  *
6563  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6564  *
6565  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6566  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6567  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6568  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6569  *
6570  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6571  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6572  * set_key callback.
6573  */
6574 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6575 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6576 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6577 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6578 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6579 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6580 				      void *data),
6581 			 void *iter_data);
6582 
6583 /**
6584  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6585  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6586  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6587  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6588  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6589  *
6590  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6591  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6592  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6593  * in removal process will be skipped.
6594  *
6595  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6596  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6597  */
6598 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6599 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6600 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6601 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6602 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6603 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6604 					  void *data),
6605 			     void *iter_data);
6606 
6607 /**
6608  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6609  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6610  * @iter: iterator function
6611  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6612  *
6613  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6614  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6615  * places while calling into the driver.
6616  *
6617  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6618  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6619  * removed.
6620  *
6621  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6622  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6623  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6624  * or not.
6625  */
6626 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6627 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6628 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6629 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6630 		     void *data),
6631 	void *iter_data);
6632 
6633 /**
6634  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6635  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6636  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6637  *
6638  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6639  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6640  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6641  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6642  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6643  * %NULL.
6644  *
6645  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6646  */
6647 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6648 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6649 
6650 /**
6651  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6652  *
6653  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6654  *
6655  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6656  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6657  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6658  */
6659 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6660 
6661 /**
6662  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6663  *
6664  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6665  *
6666  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6667  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6668  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6669  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6670  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6671  *
6672  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6673  * without connection recovery attempts.
6674  */
6675 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6676 
6677 /**
6678  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6679  *
6680  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6681  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6682  *
6683  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6684  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6685  */
6686 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6687 
6688 /**
6689  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6690  *
6691  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6692  *
6693  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6694  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6695  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6696  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6697  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6698  *
6699  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6700  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6701  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6702  * disconnect normally later.
6703  *
6704  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6705  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6706  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6707  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6708  */
6709 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6710 
6711 /**
6712  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6713  * hardware restart
6714  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6715  *
6716  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6717  * hardware restart.
6718  */
6719 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6720 
6721 /**
6722  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6723  *	rssi threshold triggered
6724  *
6725  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6726  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6727  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6728  * @gfp: context flags
6729  *
6730  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6731  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6732  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6733  */
6734 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6735 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6736 			       s32 rssi_level,
6737 			       gfp_t gfp);
6738 
6739 /**
6740  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6741  *
6742  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6743  * @gfp: context flags
6744  */
6745 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6746 
6747 /**
6748  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6749  *
6750  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6751  * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6752  *	pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6753  */
6754 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6755 			      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6756 
6757 /**
6758  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6759  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6760  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6761  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6762  *	false.
6763  *
6764  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6765  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6766  */
6767 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6768 			     unsigned int link_id);
6769 
6770 /**
6771  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6772  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6773  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6774  *
6775  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6776  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6777  * a deauth frame in this case.
6778  */
6779 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6780 					 bool block_tx);
6781 
6782 /**
6783  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6784  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6785  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6786  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6787  *
6788  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6789  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6790  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6791  */
6792 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6793 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6794 
6795 /**
6796  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6797  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6798  */
6799 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6800 
6801 /**
6802  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6803  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6804  */
6805 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6806 
6807 /**
6808  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6809  *
6810  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6811  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6812  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6813  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6814  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6815  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6816  *
6817  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6818  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6819  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6820  */
6821 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6822 				  const u8 *addr);
6823 
6824 /**
6825  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6826  * @pubsta: station struct
6827  * @tid: the session's TID
6828  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6829  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6830  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6831  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6832  *
6833  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6834  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6835  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6836  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6837  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6838  */
6839 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6840 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6841 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6842 
6843 /**
6844  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6845  *
6846  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6847  * buffer.
6848  *
6849  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6850  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6851  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6852  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6853  */
6854 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6855 
6856 /**
6857  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6858  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6859  * @addr: station mac address
6860  * @tid: the rx tid
6861  */
6862 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6863 				 unsigned int tid);
6864 
6865 /**
6866  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6867  *
6868  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6869  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6870  * reordering.
6871  *
6872  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6873  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6874  *
6875  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6876  * @addr: station mac address
6877  * @tid: the rx tid
6878  */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6879 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6880 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6881 {
6882 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6883 		return;
6884 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6885 }
6886 
6887 /**
6888  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6889  *
6890  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6891  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6892  * reordering.
6893  *
6894  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6895  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6896  *
6897  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6898  * @addr: station mac address
6899  * @tid: the rx tid
6900  */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6901 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6902 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6903 {
6904 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6905 		return;
6906 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6907 }
6908 
6909 /**
6910  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6911  *
6912  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6913  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6914  *
6915  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6916  *
6917  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6918  * @addr: station mac address
6919  * @tid: the rx tid
6920  */
6921 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6922 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6923 
6924 /* Rate control API */
6925 
6926 /**
6927  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6928  *
6929  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6930  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6931  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6932  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6933  *	to be filled in
6934  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6935  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6936  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6937  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6938  *	RTS threshold
6939  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6940  *	if the selected rate supports it
6941  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6942  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6943  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6944  */
6945 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6946 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6947 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6948 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6949 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6950 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6951 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6952 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6953 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6954 	bool bss;
6955 };
6956 
6957 /**
6958  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6959  */
6960 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6961 	/**
6962 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6963 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6964 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6965 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6966 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6967 	 */
6968 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6969 	/**
6970 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6971 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6972 	 */
6973 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6974 };
6975 
6976 struct rate_control_ops {
6977 	unsigned long capa;
6978 	const char *name;
6979 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6980 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6981 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6982 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6983 
6984 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6985 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6986 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6987 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6988 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6989 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6990 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6991 			    u32 changed);
6992 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6993 			 void *priv_sta);
6994 
6995 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6996 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6997 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6998 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6999 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7000 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
7001 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7002 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7003 
7004 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7005 				struct dentry *dir);
7006 
7007 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7008 };
7009 
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7010 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7011 				 enum nl80211_band band,
7012 				 int index)
7013 {
7014 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7015 }
7016 
7017 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7018 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7019 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7020 {
7021 	int i;
7022 
7023 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7024 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7025 			return i;
7026 
7027 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7028 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7029 
7030 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7031 	return 0;
7032 }
7033 
7034 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7035 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7036 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7037 {
7038 	unsigned int i;
7039 
7040 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7041 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7042 			return true;
7043 	return false;
7044 }
7045 
7046 /**
7047  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7048  *
7049  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7050  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7051  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7052  * the most recent rate control module decision.
7053  *
7054  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7055  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7056  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7057  *
7058  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7059  */
7060 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7061 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7062 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7063 
7064 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7065 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7066 
7067 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7068 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7069 {
7070 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7071 }
7072 
7073 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7074 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7075 {
7076 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7077 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7078 }
7079 
7080 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7081 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7082 {
7083 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7084 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7085 }
7086 
7087 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7088 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7089 {
7090 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7091 }
7092 
7093 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7094 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7095 {
7096 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7097 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7098 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7099 }
7100 
7101 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7102 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7103 {
7104 	if (p2p) {
7105 		switch (type) {
7106 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7107 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7108 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7109 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7110 		default:
7111 			break;
7112 		}
7113 	}
7114 	return type;
7115 }
7116 
7117 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7118 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7119 {
7120 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7121 }
7122 
7123 /**
7124  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7125  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7126  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7127  *
7128  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7129  */
7130 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7131 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7132 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7133 {
7134 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7135 }
7136 
7137 /**
7138  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7139  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7140  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7141  *
7142  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7143  */
7144 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7145 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7146 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7147 {
7148 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7149 }
7150 
7151 /**
7152  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7153  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7154  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7155  *
7156  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7157  */
7158 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7159 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7160 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7161 {
7162 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7163 }
7164 
7165 /**
7166  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7167  *
7168  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7169  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7170  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7171  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7172  *
7173  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7174  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7175  * matching GroupId management frame.
7176  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7177  */
7178 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7179 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7180 
7181 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7182 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7183 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7184 
7185 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7186 
7187 /**
7188  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7189  *
7190  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7191  *
7192  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7193  *
7194  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7195  * applicable.
7196  */
7197 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7198 
7199 /**
7200  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7201  * @vif: virtual interface
7202  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7203  * @gfp: allocation flags
7204  *
7205  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7206  */
7207 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7208 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7209 				    gfp_t gfp);
7210 
7211 /**
7212  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7213  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7214  * @vif: virtual interface
7215  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7216  * @band: the band to transmit on
7217  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7218  *
7219  * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7220  *
7221  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7222  */
7223 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7224 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7225 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7226 
7227 /**
7228  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7229  *				 of injected frames.
7230  *
7231  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7232  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7233  * of the skb before calling this function.
7234  *
7235  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7236  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7237  *
7238  * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7239  */
7240 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7241 				 struct net_device *dev);
7242 
7243 /**
7244  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7245  *
7246  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7247  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7248  *
7249  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7250  *
7251  * private:
7252  *
7253  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7254  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7255  */
7256 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7257 	u32 next_tsf;
7258 	bool has_next_tsf;
7259 
7260 	u8 absent;
7261 
7262 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7263 	struct {
7264 		u32 start;
7265 		u32 duration;
7266 		u32 interval;
7267 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7268 };
7269 
7270 /**
7271  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7272  *
7273  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7274  * @data: NoA tracking data
7275  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7276  *
7277  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7278  */
7279 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7280 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7281 
7282 /**
7283  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7284  *
7285  * @data: NoA tracking data
7286  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7287  */
7288 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7289 
7290 /**
7291  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7292  * @vif: virtual interface
7293  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7294  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7295  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7296  * @gfp: allocation flags
7297  *
7298  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7299  */
7300 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7301 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7302 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7303 
7304 /**
7305  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7306  *
7307  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7308  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7309  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7310  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7311  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7312  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7313  *
7314  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7315  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7316  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7317  *
7318  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7319  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7320  *
7321  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7322  */
7323 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7324 
7325 /**
7326  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7327  *
7328  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7329  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7330  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7331  *
7332  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7333  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7334  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7335  *
7336  * @sta: the station
7337  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7338  */
7339 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7340 
7341 /**
7342  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7343  *
7344  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7345  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7346  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7347  *
7348  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7349  *
7350  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7351  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7352  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7353  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7354  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7355  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7356  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7357  *
7358  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7359  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7360  */
7361 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7362 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7363 
7364 /**
7365  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7366  * (in process context)
7367  *
7368  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7369  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7370  *
7371  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7372  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7373  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7374  *
7375  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7376  */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7377 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7378 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7379 {
7380 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7381 
7382 	local_bh_disable();
7383 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7384 	local_bh_enable();
7385 
7386 	return skb;
7387 }
7388 
7389 /**
7390  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7391  *
7392  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7393  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7394  *
7395  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7396  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7397  */
7398 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7399 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7400 
7401 /**
7402  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7403  *
7404  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7405  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7406  *
7407  * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7408  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7409  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7410  */
7411 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7412 
7413 /**
7414  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7415  *
7416  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7417  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7418  *
7419  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7420  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7421  */
7422 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7423 
7424 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7425 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7426 {
7427 }
7428 
7429 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7430 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7431 
7432 /**
7433  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7434  *
7435  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7436  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7437  *
7438  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7439  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7440  *
7441  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7442  * this TXQ internally.
7443  */
7444 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7445 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7446 {
7447 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7448 }
7449 
7450 /**
7451  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7452  *
7453  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7454  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7455  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7456  *
7457  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7458  * internally.
7459  */
7460 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7461 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7462 		     bool force)
7463 {
7464 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7465 }
7466 
7467 /**
7468  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7469  *
7470  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7471  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7472  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7473  * next_txq().
7474  *
7475  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7476  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7477  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7478  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7479  * again.
7480  *
7481  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7482  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7483  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7484  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7485  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7486  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7487  *
7488  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7489  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7490  *
7491  * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7492  */
7493 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7494 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7495 
7496 /**
7497  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7498  *
7499  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7500  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7501  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7502  *
7503  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7504  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7505  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7506  */
7507 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7508 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7509 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7510 
7511 /**
7512  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7513  *
7514  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7515  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7516  *
7517  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7518  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7519  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7520  * @gfp: allocation flags
7521  */
7522 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7523 				   u8 inst_id,
7524 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7525 				   gfp_t gfp);
7526 
7527 /**
7528  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7529  *
7530  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7531  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7532  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7533  *
7534  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7535  * @match: match event information
7536  * @gfp: allocation flags
7537  */
7538 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7539 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7540 			      gfp_t gfp);
7541 
7542 /**
7543  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7544  *
7545  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7546  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7547  *
7548  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7549  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7550  *          information.
7551  * @len: frame length in bytes
7552  *
7553  * Return: the airtime estimate
7554  */
7555 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7556 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7557 			      int len);
7558 
7559 /**
7560  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7561  *
7562  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7563  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7564  *
7565  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7566  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7567  * @len: frame length in bytes
7568  *
7569  * Return: the airtime estimate
7570  */
7571 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7572 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7573 			      int len);
7574 /**
7575  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7576  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7577  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7578  *
7579  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7580  *
7581  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7582  */
7583 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7584 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7585 
7586 /**
7587  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7588  *	probe response template.
7589  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7590  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7591  *
7592  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7593  *
7594  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7595  */
7596 struct sk_buff *
7597 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7598 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7599 
7600 /**
7601  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7602  * collision.
7603  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7604  *
7605  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7606  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7607  *	aware of.
7608  */
7609 void
7610 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7611 				      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7612 
7613 /**
7614  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7615  *
7616  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7617  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7618  *
7619  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7620  *
7621  * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7622  */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7623 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7624 {
7625 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7626 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7627 
7628 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7629 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7630 }
7631 
7632 /**
7633  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7634  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7635  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7636  *
7637  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7638  *	back into the driver.
7639  *
7640  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7641  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7642  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7643  *
7644  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7645  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7646  * a sequence of calls like
7647  *
7648  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7649  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7650  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7651  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7652  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7653  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7654  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7655  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7656  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7657  *
7658  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7659  */
7660 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7661 
7662 /**
7663  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7664  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7665  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7666  *
7667  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7668  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7669  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7670  * completed after it returns.
7671  */
7672 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7673 				      u16 active_links);
7674 
7675 /**
7676  * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7677  * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7678  *
7679  * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7680  * TTLM request.
7681  */
7682 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7683 
7684 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7685 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7686 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7687 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7688 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7689 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7690 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7691 				      u32 changed);
7692 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7693 					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7694 					 int n_vifs,
7695 					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7696 
7697 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7698